manual: reorder flash driver info
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB JLINK based
453 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
454 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
460 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
464 @end itemize
465
466 @section USB RLINK based
467 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
468 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
469 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
470
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
476 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
477 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
478 @end itemize
479
480 @section USB ST-LINK based
481 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
482 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
483
484 @itemize @bullet
485 @item @b{ST-LINK}
486 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
487 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
488 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
489 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
490 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
491 @end itemize
492
493 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
494 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
495 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
496 @itemize @bullet
497 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
498 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
499 @end itemize
500
501 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
502 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
503 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
504 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
505
506 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
507 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
508 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
509
510 @section USB Other
511 @itemize @bullet
512 @item @b{USBprog}
513 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
514
515 @item @b{USB - Presto}
516 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
517
518 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
519 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
520
521 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
522 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
523
524 @item @b{Buspirate}
525 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
526
527 @item @b{opendous}
528 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
529
530 @item @b{estick}
531 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
532
533 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
534 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
535 @end itemize
536
537 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
538
539 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
540 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
541 these on the market.
542
543 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
544 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
545 of USB-based ones.
546
547 @itemize @bullet
548
549 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
550 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
551
552 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
553 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
554 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
555
556 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Wiggler2}
560 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
561
562 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
563 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
564
565 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
566 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
567
568 @item @b{arm-jtag}
569 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
570
571 @item @b{chameleon}
572 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
573
574 @item @b{Triton}
575 @* Unknown.
576
577 @item @b{Lattice}
578 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
579 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
580
581 @item @b{flashlink}
582 @* From ST Microsystems;
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
584
585 @end itemize
586
587 @section Other...
588 @itemize @bullet
589
590 @item @b{ep93xx}
591 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
592
593 @item @b{at91rm9200}
594 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
595
596 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
597 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
598
599 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
600 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
601 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
602
603 @end itemize
604
605 @node About Jim-Tcl
606 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex Jim-Tcl
608 @cindex tcl
609
610 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
611 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
612 command interpreter.
613
614 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
615 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
616 much of anything about Tcl.
617 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
618
619 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
620 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
621 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
622 OpenOCD mailing list.
623
624 @itemize @bullet
625 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
626 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
627 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
628 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
629 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
630 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
631
632 @item @b{Missing Features}
633 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
634 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
635 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
636 enabled in OpenOCD.
637
638 @item @b{Scripts}
639 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
640 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
641 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
642
643 @item @b{Commands}
644 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
645 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
646 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
647 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
648
649 @item @b{Historical Note}
650 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
651 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
652 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
653 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
654
655 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
656 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
657 @end itemize
658
659 @node Running
660 @chapter Running
661 @cindex command line options
662 @cindex logfile
663 @cindex directory search
664
665 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
666 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
667 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
668 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
669 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
670 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
671 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
672
673 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
674 tell it how each debug session should work.
675 The @option{--help} option shows:
676 @verbatim
677 bash$ openocd --help
678
679 --help | -h display this help
680 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
681 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
682 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
683 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
684 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
685 --command | -c run <command>
686 @end verbatim
687
688 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
689 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
690 To specify one or more different
691 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
692
693 @example
694 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
695 @end example
696
697 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
698 @enumerate
699 @item the current directory,
700 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
701 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
702 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Daemon Configuration
1998 @chapter Daemon Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129 @end deffn
2130
2131 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2132 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2133 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2134 output from the Tcl engine.
2135 Intended as a machine interface.
2136 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2137 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2138
2139 @end deffn
2140
2141 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2142 Specify or query the
2143 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2144 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2145 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2146 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2147 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2148 @end deffn
2149
2150 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2151 @section GDB Configuration
2152 @cindex GDB
2153 @cindex GDB configuration
2154 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2155 The ones listed here are static and global.
2156 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2157 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2158
2159 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2160 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2161 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2162 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2163 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2164 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2165 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2166 @end deffn
2167
2168 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2169 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2170 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2171 vFlash packet is received.
2172 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2173 @end deffn
2174
2175 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2176 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2177 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2178 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2179 for flash programming to work.
2180 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2181 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2182 @end deffn
2183
2184 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2185 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2186 by GDB memory read packets.
2187 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2188 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2189 @end deffn
2190
2191 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2192 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2193 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2197 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2198
2199 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2200 @end deffn
2201
2202 @anchor{eventpolling}
2203 @section Event Polling
2204
2205 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2206 where significant events can happen at any time.
2207 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2208 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2209 or to GDB.
2210
2211 Examples of such events include:
2212
2213 @itemize
2214 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2215 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2216 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2217 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2218 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2219 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2220 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2221 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2222 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2223 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2224 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2225 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2226 @end itemize
2227
2228 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2229 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2230 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2231 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2232 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2233
2234 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2235 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2236 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2237 to the various active targets.
2238 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2239 which is normally done in the background.
2240
2241 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2242 Poll the current target for its current state.
2243 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2244 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2245 specific information about the current state is printed.
2246 An optional parameter
2247 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2248
2249 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2250 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2251 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2252 @example
2253 > poll
2254 background polling: on
2255 target state: halted
2256 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2257 current mode: Supervisor
2258 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2259 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2260 >
2261 @end example
2262 @end deffn
2263
2264 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2265 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2266 @cindex config file, interface
2267 @cindex interface config file
2268
2269 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2270 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2271 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2272
2273 @quotation Note
2274 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2275 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2276 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2277 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2278 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2279 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2280 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2281 @end quotation
2282
2283 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2284 through commands in an interface configuration
2285 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2286 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2287
2288 @example
2289 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2290 @end example
2291
2292 These commands tell
2293 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2294 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2295
2296 @example
2297 # jlink interface
2298 interface jlink
2299 @end example
2300
2301 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2302
2303
2304 @section Interface Configuration
2305
2306 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2307 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2308 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2309
2310 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2311 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2312 target.
2313 @end deffn
2314
2315 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2316 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2317 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2318 @end deffn
2319 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2320 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2321 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2322 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2323 the hardware can support.
2324 @end deffn
2325
2326
2327
2328 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2329 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2330 @end deffn
2331
2332 @section Interface Drivers
2333
2334 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2335 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2336 available at run time.
2337
2338 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2339 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2340 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2341 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2342
2343 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2344 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2345 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2346 @end deffn
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2349 Displays status of RTCK option.
2350 Optionally sets that option first.
2351 @end deffn
2352 @end deffn
2353
2354 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2355 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2356 This has one driver-specific command:
2357
2358 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2359 Logs some status
2360 @end deffn
2361 @end deffn
2362
2363 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2364 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2365 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2366 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2367 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2368 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2372 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2373
2374 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2375 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2376 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2377 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2378 @example
2379 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2380 @end example
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2384 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2385 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2389 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2390 @end deffn
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2394 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2395 @end deffn
2396
2397 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2398 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2402 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2403
2404 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2405 recommended as its replacement.
2406
2407 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2408 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2409
2410 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2411 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2412 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2413 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2414 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2418 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2419 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2420 is connected to the host.
2421 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2422 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2423 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2424 @end deffn
2425
2426 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2427 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2428 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2429 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2430 @itemize @minus
2431 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2432 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2433 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2434 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2435 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2436 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2437 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2438 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2439 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2440 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2441 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2442 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2443 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2444 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2445 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2446 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2447 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2448 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2449 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2450 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2451 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2452 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2453 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2454 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2455 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2456 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2457 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2458 @end itemize
2459 @end deffn
2460
2461 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2462 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2463 default values are used.
2464 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2465 @example
2466 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2467 @end example
2468 @end deffn
2469
2470 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2471 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2472 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2473 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2474 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2475 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2476 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2477 @end deffn
2478
2479 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2480 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2481 The default value is 1.
2482 @end deffn
2483
2484 For example, the interface config file for a
2485 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2486
2487 @example
2488 interface ft2232
2489 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2490 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2491 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2492 @end example
2493 @end deffn
2494
2495 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2496 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2497 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2498 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2499 interface driver.
2500
2501 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2502 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2503 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2504
2505 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2506 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2507 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2508
2509 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2510 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2511 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2512 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2513 will be used for their customary purpose.
2514
2515 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2516 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2517 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2518 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2519
2520 @itemize @minus
2521 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2522 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2523 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2524 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2525 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2526 switching data and direction as necessary
2527 @end itemize
2528
2529 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2530 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2531
2532 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2533 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2534 default values are used.
2535 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2536 @example
2537 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2538 @end example
2539 @end deffn
2540
2541 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2542 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2543 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2544 during device selection.
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2548 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2549 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2550 is connected to the host.
2551 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2552 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2553 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2554 @end deffn
2555
2556 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2557 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2558 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2562 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2563 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2564 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2565 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2566 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2567 and initially asserted reset signals.
2568 @end deffn
2569
2570 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2571 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2572 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2573 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2574 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2575 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2576 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2577 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2578 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2579
2580 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2581 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2582 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2583 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2584 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2585 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2586
2587 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2588 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2589 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2590 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2591 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2592 are always driven by the FTDI.
2593
2594 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2595 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2596 @var{name}.
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2600 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2601 @itemize @minus
2602 @item @option{0}, drive low
2603 @item @option{1}, drive high
2604 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2605 @end itemize
2606 @end deffn
2607
2608 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2609 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2610 @end deffn
2611
2612 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2613 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2614 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2615 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2616
2617 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2618 processors which are being simulated.
2619
2620 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2621 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2622 sockets instead of TCP.
2623 @end deffn
2624
2625 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2626 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2627 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2631 something like:
2632
2633 @example
2634 interface remote_bitbang
2635 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2636 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2637 @end example
2638
2639 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2640 named mysocket:
2641
2642 @example
2643 interface remote_bitbang
2644 remote_bitbang_port 0
2645 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2646 @end example
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2650 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2651 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2652 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2655 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2656 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2657 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2658 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2662 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2663 default values are used.
2664 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2665 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2666 @example
2667 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2668 @end example
2669 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2670 @example
2671 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2672 @end example
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1})
2676 Sets the state of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters (pins 6 and 8 on the
2677 female JTAG header). These pins can be used as SRST and/or TRST provided the
2678 appropriate connections are made on the target board.
2679
2680 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST (as with an AVR board):
2681 @example
2682 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-assert \
2683 "usb_blaster pin6 1; wait 1; usb_blaster pin6 0"
2684 @end example
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2690 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2691 This has one driver-specific command:
2692
2693 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2694 Display either the address of the I/O port
2695 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2696 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2697 This is a write-once setting.
2698 @end deffn
2699 @end deffn
2700
2701 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2702 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2703
2704 @quotation Compatibility Note
2705 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2706 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2707 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2708 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2709 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2710 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2711 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2712 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2713 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2714 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2715 @end quotation
2716
2717 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2718 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2719 @end deffn
2720 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2721 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2722 @end deffn
2723 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2724 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2725 @end deffn
2726 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2727 Display the J-Link configuration.
2728 @end deffn
2729 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2730 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2731 @end deffn
2732 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2733 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2734 @end deffn
2735 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2736 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2737 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2738 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2739 @end deffn
2740 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2741 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2742 @end deffn
2743 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2744 Reset the current configuration.
2745 @end deffn
2746 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2747 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2748 @end deffn
2749 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2750 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2751 @end deffn
2752 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} serial-number
2753 Set the @var{serial-number} of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected to the host.
2754 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2755
2756 Note that there may be leading zeros in the @var{serial-number} string
2757 that will not show in the Segger software, but must be specified here.
2758 Debug level 3 output contains serial numbers if there is a mismatch.
2759
2760 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2761 @end deffn
2762 @end deffn
2763
2764 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2765 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2766 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2767 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2768 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2769
2770 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2771 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2772 This is a write-once setting.
2773 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2774
2775 @itemize @minus
2776 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2777 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2778 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2779 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2780 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2781 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2782 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2783 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2784 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2785 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2786 some versions of
2787 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2788 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2789 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2790 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2791 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2792 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2793 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2794 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2795 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2796 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2797 @end itemize
2798 @end deffn
2799
2800 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2801 Display either the address of the I/O port
2802 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2803 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2804 This is a write-once setting.
2805
2806 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2807 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2808 you may encounter a problem.
2809 @end deffn
2810
2811 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2812 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2813 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2814 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2815 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2816 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2817
2818 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2819 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2820 @quotation Tip
2821 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2822 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2823 @example
2824 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2825 > adapter_khz 500
2826 @end example
2827 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2828 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2829 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2830 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2831 large set of samples.
2832 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2833 @example
2834 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2835 @end example
2836 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2837 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2838
2839 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2840 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2841 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2842 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2843 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2844 @end quotation
2845 @end deffn
2846
2847 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2848 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2849 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2850 @end deffn
2851
2852 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2853 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2854
2855 @example
2856 interface parport
2857 parport_port 0x278
2858 parport_cable wiggler
2859 @end example
2860 @end deffn
2861
2862 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2863 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2864 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2865 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2866 @end deffn
2867 @end deffn
2868
2869 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2870 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2871 @end deffn
2872
2873 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2874 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2875 @end deffn
2876
2877 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2878 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2879
2880 @quotation Note
2881 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2882 which are not currently documented here.
2883 @end quotation
2884 @end deffn
2885
2886 @anchor{hla_interface}
2887 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2888 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2889 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2890 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2891
2892 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2893 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2894 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2895 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2896 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2897
2898 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2899 Currently Not Supported.
2900 @end deffn
2901
2902 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2903 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2907 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2908 @end deffn
2909
2910 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2911 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2912 @end deffn
2913
2914 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2915 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2916 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2917 @end deffn
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2921 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2922 @end deffn
2923
2924 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2925 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2926 @end deffn
2927
2928 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2929 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2930 @end deffn
2931
2932 @quotation Note
2933 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2934 which are not currently documented here.
2935 @end quotation
2936
2937 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2938 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2939 No arguments: print status.
2940 @end deffn
2941
2942 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2943 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2944 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2945
2946 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2947 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2948 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2949 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2950 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2951 configuration on exit.
2952
2953 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2954 pinout.
2955
2956 @end deffn
2957
2958 @section Transport Configuration
2959 @cindex Transport
2960 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2961 and the debug adapter you are using,
2962 several transports may be available to
2963 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2964 @deffn Command {transport list}
2965 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2966 version of OpenOCD.
2967 @end deffn
2968
2969 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2970 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2971
2972 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2973 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2974 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2975 adapter's driver).
2976
2977 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2978 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2979 supported by the debug adapter.
2980
2981 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2982 transport, if any.
2983 @end deffn
2984
2985 @subsection JTAG Transport
2986 @cindex JTAG
2987 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
2988 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
2989 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
2990 each of which must be explicitly declared.
2991 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
2992 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2993
2994 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2995 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2996 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2997 hla_jtag}.
2998
2999 @subsection SWD Transport
3000 @cindex SWD
3001 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3002 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3003 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3004 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3005 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3006 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3007 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3008
3009 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3010 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3011 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3012 hla_swd}.
3013
3014 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3015 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3016 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3017 expected to change.
3018 @end deffn
3019 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3020 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3021 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3022 No parameters: displays current settings.
3023 @end deffn
3024
3025 @subsection SPI Transport
3026 @cindex SPI
3027 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3028 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3029 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3030 solution for flash programming.
3031
3032 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3033 @section JTAG Speed
3034 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3035 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3036 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3037 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3038 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3039 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3040 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3041 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3042 power management software that may be active.
3043
3044 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3045 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3046 target event handler.
3047 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3048 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3049 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3050 sets up those clocks).
3051 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3052 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3053 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3054 in the target config file.
3055 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3056 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3057 config file instead.
3058 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3059 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3060 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3061
3062 @example
3063 jtag_rclk 3000
3064 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3065 @end example
3066
3067 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3068 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3069 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3070 may not be the fastest solution.
3071
3072 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3073 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3074 which support adaptive clocking.
3075
3076 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3077 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3078 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3079 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3080 than the speed specified.
3081
3082 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3083 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3084 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3085 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3086
3087 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3088 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3089 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3090 JTAG clocking after setup.
3091 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3092 If the interface device can not
3093 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3094 @end deffn
3095
3096 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3097 @cindex adaptive clocking
3098 @cindex RTCK
3099 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3100 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3101 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3102 @example
3103 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3104 jtag_rclk 3000
3105 @end example
3106 @end defun
3107
3108 @node Reset Configuration
3109 @chapter Reset Configuration
3110 @cindex Reset Configuration
3111
3112 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3113 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3114 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3115 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3116 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3117 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3118 Please see the various board files for examples.
3119
3120 @quotation Note
3121 To maintainers and integrators:
3122 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3123 Normally the board configuration file
3124 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3125 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3126
3127 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3128 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3129 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3130 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3131 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3132 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3133 @end quotation
3134
3135 @section Types of Reset
3136
3137 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3138 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3139 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3140
3141 @itemize @bullet
3142 @item
3143 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3144 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3145 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3146 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3147 @item
3148 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3149 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3150 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3151 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3152 @item
3153 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3154 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3155 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3156 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3157 @item
3158 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3159 several other types of reset.
3160 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3161 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3162 There may be individual module resets.
3163 @end itemize
3164
3165 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3166 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3167 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3168 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3169 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3170 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3171 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3172 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3173 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3174
3175 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3176 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3177
3178 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3179 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3180 common issues are:
3181
3182 @itemize @bullet
3183
3184 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3185 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3186 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3187 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3188 when either of those signals is not connected.
3189 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3190 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3191 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3192 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3193
3194 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3195 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3196 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3197 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3198
3199 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3200 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3201 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3202 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3203 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3204 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3205 hardware debouncing.
3206 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3207 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3208
3209 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3210 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3211 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3212 to use push/pull output drivers.
3213 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3214 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3215 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3216 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3217
3218 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3219 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3220 issues (not limited to errata).
3221 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3222 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3223 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3224 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3225 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3226 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3227 @end itemize
3228
3229 There can also be other issues.
3230 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3231 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3232 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3233 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3234 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3235 Agreement (NDA).
3236
3237 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3238 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3239 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3240
3241 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3242 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3243
3244 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3245
3246 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3247 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3248 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3249 allowing it to be deasserted.
3250 @end deffn
3251
3252 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3253 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3254 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3255 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3256 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3257 @end deffn
3258
3259 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3260 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3261 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3262 allowing it to be deasserted.
3263 @end deffn
3264
3265 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3266 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3267 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3268 @end deffn
3269
3270 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3271 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3272 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3273 configuration scripts.
3274
3275 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3276 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3277 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3278 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3279 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3280 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3281 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3282 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3283
3284 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3285 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3286 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3287 -- may be specified at a time.
3288 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3289 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3290 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3291 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3292 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3293
3294 @itemize
3295 @item
3296 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3297 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3298 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3299 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3300 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3301
3302 @quotation Tip
3303 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3304 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3305 @end quotation
3306
3307 @item
3308 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3309 signal implementations.
3310 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3311 indicating everything behaves normally.
3312 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3313 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3314 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3315 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3316 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3317 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3318 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3319
3320 @item
3321 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3322 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3323 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3324 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3325 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3326 while SRST is asserted.
3327 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3328 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3329
3330 @item
3331 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3332 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3333 is required to use this option.
3334 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3335 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3336 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3337 be asserted before any target connection.
3338 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3339 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3340 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3341 @end itemize
3342
3343 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3344 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3345 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3346 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3347 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3348
3349 @itemize
3350 @item
3351 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3352 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3353 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3354 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3355
3356 @item
3357 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3358 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3359 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3360 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3361 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3362 @end itemize
3363 @end deffn
3364
3365 @section Custom Reset Handling
3366 @cindex events
3367
3368 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3369 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3370 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3371 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3372 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3373 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3374
3375 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3376 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3377 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3378 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3379 want to reset everything at once.
3380
3381 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3382 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3383 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3384 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3385 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3386 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3387 needs special attention.
3388
3389 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3390 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3391 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3392 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3393 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3394 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3395 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3396 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3397
3398 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3399 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3400 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3401 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3402 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3403
3404 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3405 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3406 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3407 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3408 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3409 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3410 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3411 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3412 or potentially some other value.
3413
3414 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3415 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3416 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3417 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3418 (or their associated targets)
3419 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3420
3421 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3422 they return.
3423 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3424 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3425 @end deffn
3426
3427 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3428 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3429 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3430 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3431 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3432 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3433 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3434 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3435 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3436 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3437 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3438 @end deffn
3439
3440 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3441 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3442 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3443 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3444 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3445 @end deffn
3446
3447
3448 @node TAP Declaration
3449 @chapter TAP Declaration
3450 @cindex TAP declaration
3451 @cindex TAP configuration
3452
3453 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3454 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3455
3456 @itemize @bullet
3457 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3458 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3459 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3460 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3461 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3462 start running that code.
3463 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3464 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3465 and missing connections.
3466 @end itemize
3467
3468 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3469 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3470 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3471 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3472 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3473
3474 @section Scan Chains
3475 @cindex scan chain
3476
3477 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3478 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3479 They also need to be added to
3480 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3481 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3482 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3483 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3484 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3485 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3486 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3487 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3488
3489 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3490 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3491 command, presented in the next chapter.
3492 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3493 debugging targets.)
3494 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3495
3496 @verbatim
3497 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3498 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3499 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3500 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3501 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3502 @end verbatim
3503
3504 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3505 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3506 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3507 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3508 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3509 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3510 until they are told to do so.
3511
3512 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3513 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3514 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3515 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3516
3517 @example
3518 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3519 @end example
3520
3521 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3522 by a given chip.
3523 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3524 and so forth.
3525 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3526 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3527 both inside a single chip and between them.
3528 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3529
3530 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3531 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3532 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3533 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3534 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3535 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3536 includes commands something like this:
3537
3538 @example
3539 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3540 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3541 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3542 @end example
3543
3544 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3545 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3546 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3547
3548 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3549 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3550 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3551 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3552 @example
3553 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3554 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3555 @}
3556 @end example
3557 @end deffn
3558
3559 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3560 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3561 and their status.
3562 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3563 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3564 but systems with a JTAG router can
3565 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3566 @end deffn
3567
3568 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3569 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3570
3571 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3572 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3573
3574 @section TAP Names
3575 @cindex dotted name
3576
3577 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3578 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3579 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3580 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3581 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3582 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3583 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3584 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3585
3586 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3587 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3588 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3589
3590 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3591
3592 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3593 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3594 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3595 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3596
3597 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3598 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3599 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3600 overridable.
3601
3602 @cindex TAP naming convention
3603 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3604 and should follow this convention:
3605
3606 @itemize @bullet
3607 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3608 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3609 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3610 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3611 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3612 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3613 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3614 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3615 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3616 with a single TAP;
3617 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3618 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3619 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3620 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3621 @end itemize
3622
3623 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3624
3625 @itemize @bullet
3626 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3627 @*The length in bits of the
3628 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3629 @end itemize
3630
3631 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3632
3633 @itemize @bullet
3634 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3635 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3636 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3637 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3638 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3639 (the TAP is linked in).
3640 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3641 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3642 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3643 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3644 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3645 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3646 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3647 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3648 values that were found but not included in the list.
3649
3650 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3651 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3652 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3653 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3654 hardware to find these values.
3655 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3656 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3657 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3658 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3659 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3660 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3661 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3662 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3663 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3664 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3665 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3666 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3667 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3668 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3669 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3670 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3671 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3672 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3673 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3674 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3675 @end itemize
3676 @end deffn
3677
3678 @section Other TAP commands
3679
3680 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3681 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3682 At this writing this TAP attribute
3683 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3684 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3685 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3686 See the next section for information about the available events.
3687
3688 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3689 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3690 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3691 @end deffn
3692
3693 @section TAP Events
3694 @cindex events
3695 @cindex TAP events
3696
3697 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3698 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3699 The other applies to debugger targets,
3700 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3701
3702 The TAP events currently defined are:
3703
3704 @itemize @bullet
3705 @item @b{post-reset}
3706 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3707 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3708 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3709 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3710 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3711
3712 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3713 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3714 of any particular target.
3715 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3716 @item @b{setup}
3717 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3718 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3719 @item @b{tap-disable}
3720 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3721 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3722 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3723 @item @b{tap-enable}
3724 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3725 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3726 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3727 @end itemize
3728
3729 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3730 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3731 contents to be accurate), you might:
3732
3733 @example
3734 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3735 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3736 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3737 @}
3738 @end example
3739
3740
3741 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3742 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3743 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3744 @cindex jrc
3745
3746 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3747 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3748 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3749 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3750 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3751
3752 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3753 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3754 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3755 be visible.
3756 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3757 ignores, such as:
3758
3759 @itemize
3760 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3761 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3762 TAPs receive new instructions.
3763 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3764 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3765 @end itemize
3766
3767 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3768 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3769 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3770 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3771
3772 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3773 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3774
3775 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3776 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3777 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3778 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3779 should define TAP event handlers using
3780 code that looks something like this:
3781
3782 @example
3783 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3784 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3785 @}
3786 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3787 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3788 @}
3789 @end example
3790
3791 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3792
3793 @example
3794 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3795 @end example
3796
3797 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3798 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3799 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3800 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3801
3802 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3803 If necessary, disables the tap
3804 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3805 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3806 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3807 and "0" if it is disabled.
3808 @end deffn
3809
3810 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3811 If necessary, enables the tap
3812 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3813 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3814 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3815 and "0" if it is disabled.
3816 @end deffn
3817
3818 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3819 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3820 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3821 and "0" if it is disabled.
3822
3823 @quotation Note
3824 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3825 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3826 @end quotation
3827 @end deffn
3828
3829 @anchor{autoprobing}
3830 @section Autoprobing
3831 @cindex autoprobe
3832 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3833
3834 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3835 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3836 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3837 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3838
3839 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3840 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3841 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3842 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3843 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3844 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3845 right when they come out of reset).
3846
3847 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3848
3849 @example
3850 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3851 reset_config trst_and_srst
3852 jtag_rclk 8
3853 @end example
3854
3855 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3856 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3857
3858 @enumerate
3859 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3860 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3861 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3862 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3863 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3864 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3865 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3866 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3867 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3868 that is discovered.
3869 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3870 register, it will report it.
3871 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3872 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3873 @end enumerate
3874
3875 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3876 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3877 that's a bit more complex:
3878
3879 @example
3880 clock speed 8 kHz
3881 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3882 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3883 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3884 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3885 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3886 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3887 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3888 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3889 @end example
3890
3891 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3892 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3893 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3894 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3895 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3896 and so forth.
3897
3898 @node CPU Configuration
3899 @chapter CPU Configuration
3900 @cindex GDB target
3901
3902 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3903 You can also access these targets without GDB
3904 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3905 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3906 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3907 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3908
3909 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3910 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3911
3912 @section Target List
3913 @cindex target, current
3914 @cindex target, list
3915
3916 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3917 where each member has a name.
3918 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3919 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3920 (plural!) command.
3921 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3922 look like with more than one:
3923 @verbatim
3924 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3925 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3926 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3927 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3928 @end verbatim
3929
3930 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3931 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3932 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3933 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3934 space seen by that current target.
3935 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3936 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3937 are examples; and there are many more.
3938
3939 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3940
3941 @deffn Command {target current}
3942 Returns the name of the current target.
3943 @end deffn
3944
3945 @deffn Command {target names}
3946 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3947 @example
3948 foreach t [target names] @{
3949 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3950 @}
3951 @end example
3952 @end deffn
3953
3954 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3955 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3956
3957 @deffn Command targets [name]
3958 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3959 command names are singular.}
3960
3961 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3962 targets in a user friendly form.
3963
3964 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3965 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3966 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3967 @end deffn
3968
3969 @section Target CPU Types
3970 @cindex target type
3971 @cindex CPU type
3972
3973 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3974 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3975 when calling @command{target create}.
3976 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3977 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3978 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3979 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3980 what core-specific commands may be available
3981 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3982 and more.
3983
3984 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
3985 since there's a command to list them.
3986
3987 @anchor{targettypes}
3988 @deffn Command {target types}
3989 Lists all supported target types.
3990 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
3991
3992 @itemize @bullet
3993 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
3994 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3995 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3996 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3997 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
3998 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
3999 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4000 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4001 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4002 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4003 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4004 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4005 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4006 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4007 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4008 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4009 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4010 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4011 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4012 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4013 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4014 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4015 @itemize @minus
4016 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4017 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4018 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4019 @end itemize
4020 And two debug interfaces cores:
4021 @itemize @minus
4022 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4023 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4024 @end itemize
4025 @end itemize
4026 @end deffn
4027
4028 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4029 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4030 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4031 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4032 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4033 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4034 reflect design generations;
4035 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4036 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4037
4038 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4039 @section Target Configuration
4040
4041 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4042 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4043 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4044 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4045 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4046
4047 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4048 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4049 optional parts.
4050 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4051 command, created as part of target creation.
4052
4053 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4054 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4055 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4056 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4057 to be much more board-specific.
4058 The key steps you use might look something like this
4059
4060 @example
4061 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4062 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4063 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4064 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4065 @end example
4066
4067 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4068 on-chip SRAM.
4069 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4070 writes to target memory;
4071 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4072 GDB memory checksumming;
4073 and more.
4074
4075 @quotation Warning
4076 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4077 inaccessible when application code
4078 (such as an operating system)
4079 enables or disables the MMU.
4080 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4081 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4082 easy access to other addresses needed.
4083 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4084 @end quotation
4085
4086 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4087 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4088 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4089 controllers.
4090 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4091 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4092 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4093
4094 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4095 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4096 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4097 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4098 purposes including additional configuration.
4099
4100 @itemize @bullet
4101 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4102 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4103 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4104 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4105
4106 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4107 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4108 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4109 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4110 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4111 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4112 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4113
4114 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4115 @end itemize
4116 @end deffn
4117
4118 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4119 The options accepted by this command may also be
4120 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4121 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4122 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4123
4124 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4125 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4126 and changing its endianness.
4127
4128 @itemize @bullet
4129
4130 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4131 used to access this target.
4132
4133 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4134 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4135
4136 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4137 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4138 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4139 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4140 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4141 same event name assigns only one handler.
4142
4143 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4144 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4145 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4146 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4147 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4148 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4149 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4150
4151 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4152 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4153 or virtual address is being used.
4154
4155 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4156 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4157
4158 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4159 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4160 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4161 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4162 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4163
4164 @anchor{rtostype}
4165 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4166 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4167 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4168 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4169
4170 @end itemize
4171 @end deffn
4172
4173 @section Other $target_name Commands
4174 @cindex object command
4175
4176 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4177 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4178
4179 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4180 Once a button is created a button
4181 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4182 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4183 configure it like this:
4184
4185 @example
4186 # Create
4187 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4188 # Modify
4189 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4190 # Query
4191 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4192 # Report
4193 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4194 @end example
4195
4196 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4197 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4198
4199 @example
4200 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4201 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4202 @end example
4203
4204 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4205
4206 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4207 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4208 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4209 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4210 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4211 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4212 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4213 They are not otherwise documented here.
4214 @end deffn
4215
4216 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4217 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4218 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4219 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4220 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4221 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4222 the target side uses raw memory.
4223
4224 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4225 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4226 The script orientation comes from working with data
4227 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4228 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4229 and neither store nor return those values.
4230
4231 @itemize
4232 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4233 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4234 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4235 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4236 @end itemize
4237 @end deffn
4238
4239 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4240 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4241 @command{$target_name configure}
4242 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4243 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4244 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4245 There are a few special cases:
4246
4247 @itemize @bullet
4248 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4249 event named @var{event_name}.
4250 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4251 two parameters.
4252 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4253 This is a special case because this is set using
4254 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4255 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4256 @end itemize
4257
4258 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4259 all the targets you might use something like this:
4260
4261 @example
4262 foreach name [target names] @{
4263 set y [$name cget -endian]
4264 set z [$name cget -type]
4265 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4266 $x $name $y $z]
4267 @}
4268 @end example
4269 @end deffn
4270
4271 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4272 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4273 Displays the current target state:
4274 @code{debug-running},
4275 @code{halted},
4276 @code{reset},
4277 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4278 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4279 @end deffn
4280
4281 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4282 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4283 currently associated with this target.
4284 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4285 @end deffn
4286
4287 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4288 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4289 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4290 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4291 @end deffn
4292
4293 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4294 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4295 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4296 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4297 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4298 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4299 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4300 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4301 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4302 @end deffn
4303
4304 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4305 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4306 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4307 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4308 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4309 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4310 @end deffn
4311
4312 @anchor{targetevents}
4313 @section Target Events
4314 @cindex target events
4315 @cindex events
4316 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4317 For example:
4318 @itemize @bullet
4319 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4320 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4321 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4322 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4323 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4324 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4325 to set up system clocks or
4326 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4327 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4328 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4329 @end itemize
4330
4331 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4332 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4333 @command{target create ... -event}.
4334
4335 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4336 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4337 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4338
4339 @example
4340 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4341 echo "Reset..."
4342 reset halt
4343 @}
4344 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4345 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4346 echo "Reset..."
4347 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4348 # we need a reset init.
4349 reset init
4350 @}
4351 @end example
4352
4353 The following target events are defined:
4354
4355 @itemize @bullet
4356 @item @b{debug-halted}
4357 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4358 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4359 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4360 @item @b{early-halted}
4361 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4362 @item @b{examine-start}
4363 @* Before target examine is called.
4364 @item @b{examine-end}
4365 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4366 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4367 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4368 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4369 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4370 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4371 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4372 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4373 @* When GDB disconnects
4374 @item @b{gdb-end}
4375 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4376 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4377 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4378 @code{reset init})
4379 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4380 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4381 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4382 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4383 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4384 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4385 @item @b{gdb-start}
4386 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4387 @item @b{halted}
4388 @* The target has halted
4389 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4390 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4391 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4392 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4393 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4394 @item @b{reset-assert}
4395 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4396 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4397 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4398 it instead of asserting SRST.
4399 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4400 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4401 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4402 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4403 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4404 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4405 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4406 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4407 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4408 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4409 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4410 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4411 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4412 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4413 released on the scan chain.
4414 @item @b{reset-end}
4415 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4416 @ignore
4417 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4418 @* Currently not used
4419 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4420 @* Currently not used
4421 @end ignore
4422 @item @b{reset-init}
4423 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4424 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4425
4426 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4427 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4428 multiplexing, and so on.
4429 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4430 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4431 @item @b{reset-start}
4432 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4433 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4434
4435 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4436 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4437 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4438 @ignore
4439 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4440 @* Currently not used
4441 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4442 @* Currently not used
4443 @end ignore
4444 @item @b{resume-start}
4445 @* Before any target is resumed
4446 @item @b{resume-end}
4447 @* After all targets have resumed
4448 @item @b{resumed}
4449 @* Target has resumed
4450 @item @b{trace-config}
4451 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4452 @end itemize
4453
4454 @node Flash Commands
4455 @chapter Flash Commands
4456
4457 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4458 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4459 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4460 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4461 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4462 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4463 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4464 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4465 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4466
4467 Flash Steps:
4468 @enumerate
4469 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4470 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4471 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4472 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4473 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4474 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4475 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4476 @item GDB Flashing
4477 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4478 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4479 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4480 @end enumerate
4481
4482 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4483 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4484 so that it can't boot.
4485 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4486 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4487
4488 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4489 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4490 @cindex flash configuration
4491
4492 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4493 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4494 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4495 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4496 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4497 see the driver-specific documentation.
4498
4499 @itemize @bullet
4500 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4501 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4502 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4503 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4504 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4505 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4506 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4507 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4508 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4509 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4510 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4511 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4512 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4513 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4514 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4515 commands to the flash controller.
4516 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4517 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4518 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4519 for more information.
4520 @end itemize
4521 @quotation Note
4522 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4523 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4524 @end quotation
4525 @end deffn
4526
4527 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4528 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4529 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4530 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4531 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4532 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4533 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4534 @end deffn
4535
4536 @deffn Command {flash list}
4537 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4538 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4539 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4540 @end deffn
4541
4542 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4543 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4544 depends on the flash type.
4545 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4546 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4547 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4548 but most don't bother.
4549 @end deffn
4550
4551 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4552 @cindex flash erasing
4553 @cindex flash reading
4554 @cindex flash writing
4555 @cindex flash programming
4556 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4557
4558 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4559 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4560 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4561 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4562 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4563
4564 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4565 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4566 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4567 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4568 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4569
4570 @quotation Note
4571 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4572 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4573 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4574 back to a flash bank.
4575 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4576 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4577 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4578 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4579 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4580 @end quotation
4581
4582 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4583 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4584 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4585 disabled first.
4586 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4587 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4588 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4589
4590 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4591 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4592 up to and including @var{last}.
4593 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4594 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4595 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4596 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4597 @end deffn
4598
4599 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4600 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4601 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4602 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4603 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4604 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4605 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4606 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4607 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4608 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4609 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4610 before erase starts.
4611 @end deffn
4612
4613 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4614 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4615 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4616 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4617 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4618 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4619 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4620 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4621 before issuing this command.
4622 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4623 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4624 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4625 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4626 @end deffn
4627 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4628
4629 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4630 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4631 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4632 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4633 @end deffn
4634
4635 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4636 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4637 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4638 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4639 to the base address for each section in the image.
4640 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4641 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4642 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4643 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4644 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4645 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4646 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4647 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4648 each image section.
4649
4650 @quotation Warning
4651 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4652 data you want to preserve.
4653 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4654 sections might be erased with no notice.
4655 @itemize
4656 @item
4657 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4658 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4659 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4660 @item
4661 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4662 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4663 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4664 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4665 @end itemize
4666 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4667 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4668 @end quotation
4669
4670 @end deffn
4671
4672 @section Other Flash commands
4673 @cindex flash protection
4674
4675 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4676 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4677 and display that status.
4678 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4679 @end deffn
4680
4681 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4682 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4683 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4684 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4685 and possibly stale information.
4686 @end deffn
4687
4688 @anchor{flashprotect}
4689 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4690 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4691 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4692 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4693 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4694 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4695 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4696 @end deffn
4697
4698 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4699 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4700 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4701 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4702 @end deffn
4703
4704 @anchor{program}
4705 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4706 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4707 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4708 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4712 @section Flash Driver List
4713 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4714 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4715 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4716
4717 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4718 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4719 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4720
4721 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4722
4723 @itemize
4724 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4725 @end itemize
4726
4727 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4728 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4729 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4730 @example
4731 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4732 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4733 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4734 @end example
4735 @end deffn
4736
4737 @subsection External Flash
4738
4739 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4740 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4741 @cindex CFI
4742 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4743 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4744 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4745 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4746 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4747 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4748 configure a bus and its timings), or
4749 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4750 on the flash chip.
4751 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4752 speed up operation.
4753
4754 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4755
4756 @itemize
4757 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4758 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4759 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4760 @end itemize
4761
4762 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4763 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4764
4765 @example
4766 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4767 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4768 @end example
4769
4770 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4771 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4772 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4773
4774 @example
4775 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4776 @end example
4777
4778 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4779 @end deffn
4780
4781 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4782 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4783 @cindex SPIFI
4784 @cindex lpcspifi
4785 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4786 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4787 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4788
4789 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4790 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4791 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4792 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4793 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4794
4795 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4796 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4797 are configured by the driver.
4798
4799 @example
4800 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4801 @end example
4802
4803 @end deffn
4804
4805 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4806 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4807 @cindex SMI
4808 @cindex stmsmi
4809 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4810 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4811 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4812 SPI flash devices.
4813 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4814 flash devices can be connected.
4815
4816 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4817 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4818 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4819 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4820 the flash content.
4821
4822 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4823 to identify the memory bank.
4824 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4825 flash size, are detected automatically.
4826
4827 @example
4828 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4829 @end example
4830
4831 @end deffn
4832
4833 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4834 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4835 Microcontroller platform.
4836
4837 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4838 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4839
4840 @example
4841 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4842 @end example
4843
4844 @end deffn
4845
4846 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4847
4848 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4849 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4850 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4851 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4852 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4853 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4854
4855 @example
4856 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4857 @end example
4858 @end deffn
4859
4860 @anchor{at91samd}
4861 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4862 @cindex at91samd
4863
4864 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4865 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4866 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4867 processor to be halted.
4868 @end deffn
4869
4870 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4871 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4872 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4873 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4874 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4875 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4876
4877 @example
4878 at91samd set-security enable
4879 @end example
4880 @end deffn
4881
4882 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4883 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4884 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4885 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4886 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4887 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4888 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4889 in order to disable this feature.
4890
4891 @example
4892 at91samd eeprom
4893 at91samd eeprom 1024
4894 @end example
4895 @end deffn
4896
4897 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4898 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4899 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4900 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4901 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4902 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4903
4904 @example
4905 at91samd bootloader
4906 at91samd bootloader 16384
4907 @end example
4908 @end deffn
4909
4910 @end deffn
4911
4912 @anchor{at91sam3}
4913 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
4914 @cindex at91sam3
4915 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
4916 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
4917 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
4918 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
4919 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
4920 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
4921 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
4922 chips are confirmed.}
4923
4924 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
4925 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
4926 the following fixed locations:
4927
4928 @example
4929 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
4930 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4931 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
4932 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
4933 @end example
4934
4935 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
4936 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
4937 to the @command{flash bank} command:
4938
4939 @itemize
4940 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
4941 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
4942 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
4943 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
4944 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
4945 @end itemize
4946
4947 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
4948
4949 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
4950 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
4951 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
4952 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
4953 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
4954 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
4955 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
4956
4957 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
4958 modifies that GPNVM bit.
4959 @end deffn
4960
4961 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
4962 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
4963 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
4964 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
4965 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
4966 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
4967 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
4968 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
4969 @end deffn
4970
4971 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
4972 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
4973 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
4974 @end deffn
4975 @end deffn
4976
4977 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
4978 @cindex at91sam4
4979 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
4980 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4981 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4982 @end deffn
4983
4984 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
4985 @cindex at91sam4l
4986 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
4987 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4988 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4989
4990 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
4991 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
4992 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
4993 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
4994 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
4995 @end deffn
4996 @end deffn
4997
4998 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
4999 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5000 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5001 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5002 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5003
5004 @example
5005 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5006 @end example
5007
5008 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5009 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5010
5011 @itemize
5012 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5013 @item @var{banks}
5014 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5015 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5016 @item @var{pages_size}
5017 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5018 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5019 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5020 @end itemize
5021
5022 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5023 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5024 will be autoconfigured.
5025 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5026
5027 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5028 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5029 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5030 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5031 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5032
5033 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5034 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5035 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5036 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5037 are not truly general purpose).
5038 @quotation Note
5039 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5040 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5041 @end quotation
5042 @end deffn
5043 @end deffn
5044
5045 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5046 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5047 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5048 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5049 @end deffn
5050
5051 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5052 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5053 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5054 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5055 autoconfigures itself.
5056 @example
5057 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5058 @end example
5059 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5060 supported.}
5061 @end deffn
5062
5063 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5064 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5065 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5066 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5067 microcontroller families from NXP.
5068
5069 @quotation Note
5070 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5071 driver:
5072 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5073 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5074 @end quotation
5075
5076 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5077 which must appear in the following order:
5078
5079 @itemize
5080 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5081 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5082 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5083 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5084 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5085 LPC43x[2357])
5086 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5087 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5088 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5089 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5090 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5091 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5092 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5093 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5094 at which the core is running
5095 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5096 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5097 @quotation Note
5098 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5099 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5100 However, if you do provide it,
5101 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5102 @end quotation
5103 @end itemize
5104
5105 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5106
5107 @example
5108 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5109 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5110 @end example
5111
5112 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5113 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5114 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5115 @end deffn
5116 @end deffn
5117
5118 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5119 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5120 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5121 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5122 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5123 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5124
5125 @example
5126 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5127 @end example
5128 @end deffn
5129
5130 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5131 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5132 from NXP.
5133
5134 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5135 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5136 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5137 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5138 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5139 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5140 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5141 you start the PLL.
5142
5143 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5144
5145 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5146 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5147 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5148
5149 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5150 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5151 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5152 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5153 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5154 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5155 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5156
5157 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5158 @example
5159 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5160 @end example
5161
5162 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5163 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5164 @code{flash banks} command.
5165
5166 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5167 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5168 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5169 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5170 a known signature.
5171 Example:
5172 @example
5173 lpc2900 signature 0
5174 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5175 @end example
5176 @end deffn
5177
5178 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5179 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5180 saves it to a file in binary format.
5181 Example:
5182 @example
5183 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5184 @end example
5185 @end deffn
5186
5187 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5188 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5189 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5190 command:
5191
5192 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5193 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5194 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5195 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5196
5197 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5198 Example:
5199 @example
5200 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5201 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5202 @end example
5203 @end deffn
5204
5205 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5206 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5207 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5208 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5209 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5210 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5211 912 bytes.
5212 @quotation Attention
5213 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5214 @end quotation
5215 Example:
5216 @example
5217 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5218 @end example
5219 @end deffn
5220
5221 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5222 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5223 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5224 after the next power cycle.
5225 @quotation Attention
5226 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5227 @end quotation
5228 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5229 Example:
5230 @example
5231 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5232 flash info 0
5233 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5234 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5235 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5236 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5237 @end example
5238 @end deffn
5239
5240 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5241 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5242 effective after the next power cycle.
5243 @quotation Attention
5244 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5245 @end quotation
5246 Examples:
5247 @example
5248 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5249 @end example
5250 @end deffn
5251 @end deffn
5252
5253 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5254 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5255 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5256
5257 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5258 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5259 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5260 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5261
5262 @example
5263 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5264 @end example
5265 @end deffn
5266
5267 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5268 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5269 and integrate flash memory.
5270
5271 @example
5272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5274 @end example
5275
5276 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5277 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5278 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5279 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5280 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5281 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5282 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5283 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5284 @end deffn
5285 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5286 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5287 This will remove any Code Protection.
5288 @end deffn
5289 @end deffn
5290
5291 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5292 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5293 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5294 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5295 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5296
5297 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5298 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5299
5300 @example
5301 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5302 @end example
5303
5304 psoc4-specific commands
5305 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5306 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5307
5308 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5309 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5310
5311 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5312 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5313 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5314
5315 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5316 @end deffn
5317
5318 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5319 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5320
5321 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5322 @end deffn
5323 @end deffn
5324
5325 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5326 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5327 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5328 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5329 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5330 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5331 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5332 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5333
5334 @example
5335 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5336 @end example
5337
5338 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5339 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5340 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5341 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5342 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5343 disabled.
5344
5345 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5346 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5347 @quotation Warning
5348 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5349 applied to all of them.
5350 @end quotation
5351 @end deffn
5352 @end deffn
5353
5354 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5355 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5356 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5357 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5358 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5359
5360 @example
5361 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5362 @end example
5363
5364 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5365 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5366 the flash driver.
5367
5368 @example
5369 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5370 @end example
5371
5372 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5373 as per the following example.
5374 @example
5375 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5376 @end example
5377
5378 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5379 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5380 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5381 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5382 are defined:
5383
5384 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5385 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5386 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5387 @end deffn
5388
5389 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5390 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5391 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5392 @end deffn
5393
5394 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5395 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5396 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5397 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5398 @end deffn
5399
5400 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5401 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5402 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5403 @end deffn
5404 @end deffn
5405
5406 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5407 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5408 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5409 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5410 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5411
5412 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5413 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5414 the flash driver.
5415
5416 @example
5417 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5418 @end example
5419
5420 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5421
5422 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5423 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5424 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5425 @end deffn
5426
5427 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5428 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5429 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5430 @end deffn
5431 @end deffn
5432
5433 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5434 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5435 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5436 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5437 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5438
5439 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5440 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5441 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5442 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5443 second bank.
5444
5445 @example
5446 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5447 @end example
5448
5449 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5450
5451 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5452 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5453 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5454 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5455 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5456 @end deffn
5457 @end deffn
5458
5459 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5460 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5461 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5462 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5463 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5464
5465 @example
5466 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5467 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5468 @end example
5469
5470 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5471 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5472 for the specified flash bank.
5473 @end deffn
5474 @end deffn
5475
5476 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5477 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5478 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5479 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5480 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5481
5482 @example
5483 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5484 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5485 @end example
5486
5487 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5488 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5489 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5490
5491 @itemize @bullet
5492 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5493 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5494 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5495 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5496 @end itemize
5497 @end deffn
5498
5499 @end deffn
5500
5501 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5502 @cindex str9xpec
5503
5504 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5505 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5506 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5507 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5508
5509 Here is some background info to help
5510 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5511 the str9:
5512 @enumerate
5513 @item
5514 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5515 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5516 @item
5517 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5518 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5519 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5520 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5521 @end enumerate
5522
5523 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5524 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5525 configured for flash bank 0.
5526 @example
5527 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5528 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5529 jtag_reset 0 1
5530 # turn off target polling
5531 poll off
5532 # disable str9 core
5533 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5534 # read option bytes
5535 str9xpec options_read 0
5536 # re-enable str9 core
5537 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5538 poll on
5539 reset halt
5540 @end example
5541 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5542 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5543 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5544 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5545
5546 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5547
5548 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5549 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5550 @end deffn
5551
5552 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5553 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5554 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5555 @end deffn
5556
5557 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5558 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5559 erase the device.
5560 @end deffn
5561
5562 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5563 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5564 @end deffn
5565
5566 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5567 Configure str9 boot bank.
5568 @end deffn
5569
5570 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5571 Configure str9 lvd source.
5572 @end deffn
5573
5574 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5575 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5576 @end deffn
5577
5578 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5579 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5580 @end deffn
5581
5582 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5583 Read str9 option bytes.
5584 @end deffn
5585
5586 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5587 Write str9 option bytes.
5588 @end deffn
5589
5590 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5591 unlock str9 device.
5592 @end deffn
5593
5594 @end deffn
5595
5596 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5597 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5598 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5599 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5600
5601 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5602
5603 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5604 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5605 @end deffn
5606
5607 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5608 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5609 @end deffn
5610
5611 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5612 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5613 the flash clock.
5614 @end deffn
5615 @end deffn
5616
5617 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5618 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5619 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5620 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5621 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5622 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5623 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5624
5625 @example
5626 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5627 @end example
5628 @end deffn
5629
5630 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5631 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5632 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5633 and SWD interface.
5634 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5635 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5636
5637 @example
5638 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5639 @end example
5640
5641 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5642
5643 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5644 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5645 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5646 @end deffn
5647
5648 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5649 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5650 @end deffn
5651 @end deffn
5652
5653 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5654 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5655 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5656
5657 @example
5658 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5659 @end example
5660
5661 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5662
5663 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5664 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5665 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5666 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5667 code.
5668 @end deffn
5669
5670 @end deffn
5671
5672 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5673 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5674 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5675 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5676
5677 @example
5678 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5679 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5680 @end example
5681
5682 @itemize @bullet
5683 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5684 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5685 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5686 @end itemize
5687
5688 Example usage:
5689 @example
5690 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5691 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5692 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5693 @} else @{
5694 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5695 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5696 @}
5697 @end example
5698 @end deffn
5699
5700 @section NAND Flash Commands
5701 @cindex NAND
5702
5703 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5704 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5705 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5706
5707 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5708 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5709 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5710 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5711 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5712 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5713
5714 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5715 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5716 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5717 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5718 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5719 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5720 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5721 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5722 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5723 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5724
5725 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5726 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5727 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5728 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5729 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5730 every 512 bytes of data.
5731
5732 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5733 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5734 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5735 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5736 ECC mode is used.
5737
5738 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5739 @enumerate
5740 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5741 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5742 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5743 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5744 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5745 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5746 to access that device.
5747 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5748 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5749 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5750 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5751 de-brick a board.
5752 @end enumerate
5753
5754 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5755 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5756 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5757 are only 32 bits wide.
5758 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5759 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5760 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5761 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5762
5763 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5764 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
5765 @cindex NAND configuration
5766
5767 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5768 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5769 OpenOCD has initialized.
5770
5771 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5772 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5773 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5774 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5775 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5776 they were a single (larger) device.
5777 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5778 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5779
5780 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5781 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5782 configuration files, not interactively.
5783
5784 @itemize @bullet
5785 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5786 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5787 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5788 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5789 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5790 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5791 commands to the NAND controller.
5792 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5793 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5794 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5795 for more information.
5796 @end itemize
5797 @end deffn
5798
5799 @deffn Command {nand list}
5800 Prints a summary of each device declared
5801 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5802 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5803 @example
5804 > nand list
5805 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5806 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5807 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5808 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5809 >
5810 @end example
5811 @end deffn
5812
5813 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5814 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5815 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5816 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5817 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5818 it with most other NAND commands.
5819 @end deffn
5820
5821 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5822
5823 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5824 @cindex NAND reading
5825 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5826 starting at the specified offset.
5827 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5828
5829 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5830 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5831
5832 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
5833 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
5834 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
5835
5836 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
5837 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
5838 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
5839 method which handled that error correction.
5840
5841 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
5842 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
5843 @itemize @bullet
5844 @item no oob_* parameter
5845 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
5846 @item @code{oob_raw}
5847 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
5848 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
5849 spare areas associated with each data page.
5850 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
5851 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
5852 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
5853 @item @code{oob_only}
5854 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
5855 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
5856 spare areas associated with each data page.
5857 @end itemize
5858 @end deffn
5859
5860 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
5861 @cindex NAND erasing
5862 @cindex NAND programming
5863 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
5864 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
5865 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5866 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5867 If those parameters are not specified,
5868 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
5869 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5870
5871 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
5872 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
5873 block marker.
5874 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
5875 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
5876 @end deffn
5877
5878 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
5879 @cindex NAND writing
5880 @cindex NAND programming
5881 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
5882 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
5883 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
5884 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5885
5886 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5887 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5888
5889 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5890 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
5891 past the end of the device.
5892 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
5893 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
5894 if that's being written.)
5895
5896 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
5897 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
5898 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
5899
5900 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
5901 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
5902 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
5903 @itemize @bullet
5904 @item no oob_* parameter
5905 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5906 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
5907 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5908 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
5909 with hardware-computed ECC data.
5910 @item @code{oob_only}
5911 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
5912 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
5913 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
5914 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
5915 @item @code{oob_raw}
5916 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
5917 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
5918 un-altered OOB.
5919 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5920 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
5921 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
5922 @item @code{oob_softecc}
5923 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5924 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
5925 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
5926 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
5927 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
5928 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
5929 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5930 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
5931 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
5932 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
5933 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
5934 @end itemize
5935 @end deffn
5936
5937 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
5938 @cindex NAND verification
5939 @cindex NAND programming
5940 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
5941 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
5942 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5943
5944 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5945 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5946
5947 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5948 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
5949 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
5950 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
5951 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
5952
5953 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
5954 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
5955 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
5956
5957 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
5958 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
5959 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
5960 be removed in a future release.
5961 @end deffn
5962
5963 @subsection Other NAND commands
5964 @cindex NAND other commands
5965
5966 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
5967 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
5968 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
5969 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
5970 continues for @var{length} bytes.
5971 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5972 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5973 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5974
5975 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
5976 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
5977 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
5978 @end deffn
5979
5980 @deffn Command {nand info} num
5981 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5982 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
5983 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
5984 status for each block.
5985 @end deffn
5986
5987 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
5988 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
5989 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5990
5991 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
5992 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
5993 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
5994 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
5995 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
5996
5997 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
5998 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
5999 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6000 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6001 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6002 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6003 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6004 @end deffn
6005
6006 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6007 @subsection NAND Driver List
6008 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6009 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6010 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6011
6012 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6013 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6014 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6015 address of the ECC controller.
6016 @example
6017 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6018 @end example
6019 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6020 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6021 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6022 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6023 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6024 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6025 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6026 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6027 @end deffn
6028 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6029 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6030 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6031 @end deffn
6032
6033 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6034 properly configured for input or output.
6035 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6036 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6037 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6038 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6039 @end deffn
6040 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6041 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6042 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6043 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6044 @end deffn
6045 @end deffn
6046
6047 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6048 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6049 chips from Texas Instruments.
6050 It takes three extra parameters:
6051 address of the NAND chip;
6052 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6053 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6054 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6055 @example
6056 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6057 @end example
6058 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6059 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6060 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6061 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6062 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6063 @end deffn
6064
6065 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6066 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6067 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6068 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6069 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6070 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6071 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6072 @end deffn
6073
6074 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6075 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6076 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6077 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6078 @end deffn
6079 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6080
6081 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6082 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6083 should work for this chip aswell.
6084 @end deffn
6085
6086 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6087 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6088 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6089 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6090 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6091 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6092 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6093 @example
6094 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6095 @end example
6096 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6097 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6098 without parameter query status.
6099 @end deffn
6100 @end deffn
6101
6102 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6103 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6104 parameter: the address of the controller.
6105 @example
6106 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6107 @end example
6108 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6109 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6110 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6111 change any behavior.
6112 @end deffn
6113
6114 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6115 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6116 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6117 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6118 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6119 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6120 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6121 specialized commands.
6122 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6123 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6124 change any behavior.
6125 @end deffn
6126
6127 @section mFlash
6128
6129 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6130 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6131
6132 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6133 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6134 address @var{base}.
6135 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6136 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6137
6138 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6139
6140 @example
6141 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6142 @end example
6143
6144 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6145
6146 @example
6147 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6148 @end example
6149 @end deffn
6150
6151 @subsection mFlash commands
6152 @cindex mFlash commands
6153
6154 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6155 Configure mflash PLL.
6156 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6157 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6158 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6159 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6160 @end deffn
6161
6162 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6163 Configure bootable option.
6164 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6165 (4kB) for boot.
6166 @end deffn
6167
6168 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6169 Configure storage information.
6170 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6171 written.
6172 @end deffn
6173
6174 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6175 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6176 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6177 @end deffn
6178
6179 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6180 Probe mflash.
6181 @end deffn
6182
6183 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6184 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6185 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6186 @end deffn
6187
6188 @node Flash Programming
6189 @chapter Flash Programming
6190
6191 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6192 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6193 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6194
6195 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6196 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6197
6198 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6199 @enumerate
6200 @item 'init' is executed.
6201 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6202 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6203 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6204 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6205 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6206 @end enumerate
6207
6208 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6209
6210 @example
6211 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6212 # are optional parameters
6213 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6214 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6215
6216 # binary files need the flash address passing
6217 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6218 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6219 @end example
6220
6221 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6222 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6223 @cindex PLD
6224 @cindex FPGA
6225
6226 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6227 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6228 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6229 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6230 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6231 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6232 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6233
6234 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6235
6236 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6237 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6238 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6239
6240 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6241 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6242
6243 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6244 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6245 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6246 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6247 behavior.
6248 @end deffn
6249
6250 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6251 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6252 @end deffn
6253
6254 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6255 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6256 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6257 @end deffn
6258
6259 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6260
6261 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6262 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6263 that particular type of PLD.
6264
6265 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2
6266 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6267 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6268 No driver-specific PLD definition options are used,
6269 and one driver-specific command is defined.
6270
6271 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6272 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6273 for FPGA @var{num}.
6274 @end deffn
6275 @end deffn
6276
6277 @node General Commands
6278 @chapter General Commands
6279 @cindex commands
6280
6281 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6282 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6283 commands are documented elsewhere.
6284
6285 Intent:
6286 @itemize @bullet
6287 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6288 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6289 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6290 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6291
6292 @item @b{From the human}
6293 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6294 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6295
6296 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6297 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6298 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6299
6300 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6301 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6302 port is 5555.
6303 @end itemize
6304
6305
6306 @section Daemon Commands
6307
6308 @deffn {Command} exit
6309 Exits the current telnet session.
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6313 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6314 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6315 Not every command provides helptext.
6316
6317 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6318 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6319 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6320 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6321 @end deffn
6322
6323 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6324 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6325 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6326 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6327 Useful in connection with script files
6328 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6329 @end deffn
6330
6331 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6332 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6333 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6334 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6335 @end deffn
6336
6337 @anchor{debuglevel}
6338 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6339 @cindex message level
6340 Display debug level.
6341 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6342 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6343 Level 0 is error messages only;
6344 level 1 adds warnings;
6345 level 2 adds informational messages;
6346 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6347 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6348 the command line along with the location of that log
6349 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6350 @xref{Running}.
6351 @end deffn
6352
6353 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6354 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6355 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6356 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6357 @example
6358 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6359 @end example
6360 @end deffn
6361
6362 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6363 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6364 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6368 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6369 @end deffn
6370
6371 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6372 @section Target State handling
6373 @cindex reset
6374 @cindex halt
6375 @cindex target initialization
6376
6377 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6378 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6379 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6380 a current target which is used to perform the
6381 various operations. The current target may be changed
6382 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6383 target which should become current.
6384
6385 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6386 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6387 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6388 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6389 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6390
6391 @emph{With no arguments}:
6392 list all available registers for the current target,
6393 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6394 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6395 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6396 are flagged as such.
6397
6398 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6399 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6400 bypassing any internal cache.
6401
6402 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6403 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6404 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6405 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6406 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6407 relevant module will flush such values.
6408
6409 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6410 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6411
6412 @example
6413 > reg
6414 ===== ARM registers
6415 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6416 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6417 (2) r2 (/32)
6418 ...
6419 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6420 >
6421 @end example
6422 @end deffn
6423
6424 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6425 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6426 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6427 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6428 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6429 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6430 (and enter debug mode).
6431 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6432
6433 @quotation Warning
6434 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6435 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6436 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6437 power mode by gating the core clock;
6438 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6439
6440 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6441 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6442 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6443 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6444 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6445 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6446
6447 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6448 work with a JTAG debugger.
6449 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6450 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6451 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6452 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6453 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6454 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6455 @end quotation
6456
6457 @end deffn
6458
6459 @deffn Command resume [address]
6460 Resume the target at its current code position,
6461 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6462 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6463 @end deffn
6464
6465 @deffn Command step [address]
6466 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6467 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6468 @end deffn
6469
6470 @anchor{resetcommand}
6471 @deffn Command reset
6472 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6473 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6474 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6475 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6476 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6477 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6478
6479 The optional parameter specifies what should
6480 happen after the reset.
6481 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6482 The other options will not work on all systems.
6483 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6484
6485 @itemize @minus
6486 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6487 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6488 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6489 @end itemize
6490 @end deffn
6491
6492 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6493 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6494 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6495 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6496 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6497 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6498 state.
6499 @end deffn
6500
6501 @section I/O Utilities
6502
6503 These commands are available when
6504 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6505 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6506 notably the ZY1000.
6507 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6508
6509 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6510
6511 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6512 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6513 the text file @file{filename}.
6514 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6515 The last string is followed by a newline.
6516 @end deffn
6517
6518 @deffn Command cat filename
6519 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6520 @end deffn
6521
6522 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6523 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6524 into @file{dest_filename}.
6525 @end deffn
6526
6527 @deffn Command ip
6528 @emph{No description provided.}
6529 @end deffn
6530
6531 @deffn Command ls
6532 @emph{No description provided.}
6533 @end deffn
6534
6535 @deffn Command mac
6536 @emph{No description provided.}
6537 @end deffn
6538
6539 @deffn Command meminfo
6540 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6541 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6542 @end deffn
6543
6544 @deffn Command peek
6545 @emph{No description provided.}
6546 @end deffn
6547
6548 @deffn Command poke
6549 @emph{No description provided.}
6550 @end deffn
6551
6552 @deffn Command rm filename
6553 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6554 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6555 @end deffn
6556
6557 @deffn Command trunc filename
6558 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6562 @section Memory access commands
6563 @cindex memory access
6564
6565 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6566 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6567 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6568 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6569
6570 @enumerate
6571 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6572 to change the current target.
6573 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6574 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6575 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6576 @end enumerate
6577
6578 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6579 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6580 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6581 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6582 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6583 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6584 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6585 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6586 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6587 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6588 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6589 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6590 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6591 @end deffn
6592
6593 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6594 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6595 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6596 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6597 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6598 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6599 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6600 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6601 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6602 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6603 @end deffn
6604
6605 @anchor{imageaccess}
6606 @section Image loading commands
6607 @cindex image loading
6608 @cindex image dumping
6609
6610 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6611 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6612 binary file named @var{filename}.
6613 @end deffn
6614
6615 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6616 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6617 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6621 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6622 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6623 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6624 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6625 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6626 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6627 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6628 separately.
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6632 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6633 The file format may optionally be specified
6634 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6635 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6636 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6637 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6638 @example
6639 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6640 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6641 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6642 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6643 $address $length
6644 @}
6645 @end example
6646 @end deffn
6647
6648 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6649 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6650 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6651 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6652 The file format may optionally be specified
6653 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6654 @end deffn
6655
6656 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6657 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6658 The file format may optionally be specified
6659 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6660 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6661 @end deffn
6662
6663
6664 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6665 @cindex breakpoint
6666 @cindex watchpoint
6667
6668 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6669 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6670 watchpoints.
6671 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6672
6673 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6674 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6675 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6676 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6677 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6678 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6679
6680 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6681 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6685 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6689 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6690 @end deffn
6691
6692 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6693 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6694 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6695 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6696 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6697 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6698 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6699 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6700 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @section Misc Commands
6704
6705 @cindex profiling
6706 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6707 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6708 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6709 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6710 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6711 limit the address range.
6712 @end deffn
6713
6714 @deffn Command {version}
6715 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6719 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6720 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6721 @end deffn
6722
6723 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6724 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6725 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6726 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6727
6728 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6729 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6730 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6731 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6732
6733 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6734 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6735 @cindex tracing
6736 @cindex ETM
6737 @cindex ETB
6738
6739 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6740 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6741 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6742
6743 @itemize
6744 @item
6745 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6746 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6747 supports such an interface.
6748 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6749 and trace port support.)
6750 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6751 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6752 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6753 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6754 in the board-specific configuration file.
6755 @item
6756 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6757 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6758 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6759 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6760 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6761 @end itemize
6762
6763 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6764
6765 @quotation Issues
6766 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6767 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6768
6769 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6770 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6771 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6772 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6773 dummy trace port driver}.
6774
6775 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6776 as well as tracing only during specific states
6777 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6778
6779 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6780 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6781 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6782 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6783 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6784
6785 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6786 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6787 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6788 this original style of JTAG access.
6789 @end quotation
6790
6791 @subsection ETM Configuration
6792 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6793
6794 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6795 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6796 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6797
6798 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6799 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6800 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6801 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6802 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6803 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6804 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6805 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6806 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6807
6808 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6809 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6810 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6811
6812 @quotation Warning
6813 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6814 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6815 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6816 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6817 @end quotation
6818
6819 @quotation Note
6820 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6821 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6822 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6823 what CPU activities are traced.
6824 @end quotation
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @deffn Command {etm info}
6828 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6829 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6830 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6831 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6832 @end deffn
6833
6834 @deffn Command {etm status}
6835 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6836 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6837 Did trace data overflow?
6838 Was it triggered?
6839 @end deffn
6840
6841 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6842 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6843 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6844 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6845 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6846
6847 @itemize
6848 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6849 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6850 The value is one of
6851 @option{none} (save nothing),
6852 @option{data} (save data),
6853 @option{address} (save addresses),
6854 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6855 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6856 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6857 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6858 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6859 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6860 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6861 trace stream without an image of the code.
6862 @end itemize
6863 @end deffn
6864
6865 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6866 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
6867 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
6868 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
6869 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
6870
6871 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
6872 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
6873 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
6877
6878 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
6879 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
6880 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
6881
6882 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
6883 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
6884 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
6885 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
6886 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
6887 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
6888 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
6889
6890 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
6891
6892 @itemize
6893 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
6894 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
6895 for instruction access within that function's body.
6896 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
6897 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
6898 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
6899 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
6900 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
6901 combining one of the above models with a counter.
6902 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
6903 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
6904 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
6905 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
6906 @item @emph{... more}
6907 @end itemize
6908
6909 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
6910 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
6911
6912 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
6913 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
6914 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
6915 @end deffn
6916
6917 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
6918 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
6919 @end deffn
6920
6921 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
6922 Opens an image file.
6923 @end deffn
6924
6925 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
6926 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
6927 @end deffn
6928
6929 @deffn Command {etm start}
6930 Starts trace data collection.
6931 @end deffn
6932
6933 @deffn Command {etm stop}
6934 Stops trace data collection.
6935 @end deffn
6936
6937 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
6938 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
6939
6940 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
6941
6942 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
6943 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6944 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
6945 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
6946 any trace data collection.}
6947 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
6948 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
6949 @end deffn
6950 @end deffn
6951
6952 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
6953 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
6954 to use on-chip ETB memory.
6955 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
6956 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
6957 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
6958 @end deffn
6959 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
6960 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
6961 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
6962 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
6963 trace trigger becomes active.
6964
6965 @itemize
6966 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
6967 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
6968 afterwards.
6969 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
6970 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
6971 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
6972 what caused that event to happen.
6973 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
6974 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
6975 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
6976 how the event caused trouble.
6977 @end itemize
6978 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
6979 @end deffn
6980
6981 @end deffn
6982
6983 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
6984 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
6985 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
6986 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
6987 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
6988
6989 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
6990 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
6991
6992 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
6993 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
6994 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
6995 @end deffn
6996
6997 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
6998 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
6999 @end deffn
7000
7001 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7002 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7003 @end deffn
7004 @end deffn
7005
7006
7007 @section Generic ARM
7008 @cindex ARM
7009
7010 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7011 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7012 commands that may be available.
7013
7014 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7015 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7016 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7017 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7018 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7019 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7020 @end deffn
7021
7022 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7023 @cindex disassemble
7024 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7025 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7026 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7027 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7028 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7029 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7030 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7031
7032 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7033 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7034 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7035 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7036 with a handful of exceptions.
7037 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7038 @end deffn
7039
7040 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7041 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7042 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7043 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7044 and using the MCR instruction.
7045 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7046 an ARM register.)
7047 @end deffn
7048
7049 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7050 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7051 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7052 and the MRC instruction.
7053 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7054 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7055 an ARM register.)
7056 @end deffn
7057
7058 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7059 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7060 core mode if necessary.
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7064 @cindex ARM semihosting
7065 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7066
7067 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7068 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7069 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7070 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7071 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7072 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7076 @cindex ARMv4
7077 @cindex ARMv5
7078
7079 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7080 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7081 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7082 variant.
7083
7084 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7085 @cindex ARM7
7086 @cindex ARM9
7087
7088 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7089 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7090 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7091 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7092
7093 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7094 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7095 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7096 instead of breakpoints.
7097 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7098
7099 This should be
7100 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7101 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7102 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7103 @end deffn
7104
7105 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7106 @cindex DCC
7107 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7108 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7109 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7110
7111 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7112 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7113 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7114 @end deffn
7115
7116 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7117 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7118 that don't check completion of the operation.
7119 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7120
7121 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7122 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7123 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7124 @end deffn
7125
7126 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7127 @cindex ARM720T
7128
7129 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7130 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7131 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7132 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7133
7134 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7135 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7136 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7137
7138 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7139 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7140 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7141 @end deffn
7142
7143 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7144 @cindex ARM9
7145
7146 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7147 integer processors.
7148 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7149
7150 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7151 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7152 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7153 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7154
7155 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7156 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7157 @cindex vector_catch
7158 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7159 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7160 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7161 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7162 to those hardware vectors.
7163
7164 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7165 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7166 vector catch hardware to intercept
7167 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7168 @option{none} of them,
7169 or a list with one or more of the following:
7170 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7171 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7175 @cindex ARM920T
7176
7177 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7178 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7179 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7180 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7181 and ARM9 commands.
7182
7183 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7184 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7185 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7186 @end deffn
7187
7188 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7189 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7190 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7191 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7192 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7193 (Not all registers can be written.)
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7197 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7198 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7199
7200 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7201 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7202 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7203 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7204 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7205 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7206 @end deffn
7207
7208 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7209 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7210 @end deffn
7211
7212 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7213 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7214 @end deffn
7215
7216 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7217 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7218
7219 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7220 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7221 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7222 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7223 and ARM9 commands.
7224
7225 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7226 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7227
7228 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7229 Print information about the caches found.
7230 @end deffn
7231
7232 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7233 @cindex ARM966E
7234
7235 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7236 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7237 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7238 and ARM9 commands.
7239
7240 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7241 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7242 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7243 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7244 ARM966E-S TRM.
7245 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7246 as required for BIST support.
7247 @end deffn
7248
7249 @subsection XScale specific commands
7250 @cindex XScale
7251
7252 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7253
7254 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7255 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7256 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7257 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7258 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7259 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7260 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7261
7262 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7263 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7264 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7265 the mini-IC.
7266
7267 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7268 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7269 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7270 code layout in memory:
7271 @example
7272 _vectors:
7273 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7274 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7275 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7276 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7277 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7278 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7279 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7280 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7281 .org 0x100
7282 .long real_reset_vector
7283 .long real_ui_handler
7284 .long real_swi_handler
7285 .long real_pf_abort
7286 .long real_data_abort
7287 .long 0 /* unused */
7288 .long real_irq_handler
7289 .long real_fiq_handler
7290 @end example
7291
7292 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7293 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7294 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7295 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7296 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7297 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7298 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7299 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7300 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7301 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7302 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7303 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7304 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7305 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7306 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7307 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7308 software.
7309
7310 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7311 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7312 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7313 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7314
7315 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7316 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7317 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7318 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7319 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7320 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7321 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7322 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7323 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7324
7325 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7326 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7327
7328 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7329 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7330 @end deffn
7331
7332 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7333 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7334 @end deffn
7335
7336 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7337 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7338 @end deffn
7339
7340 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7341 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7342 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7343 @end deffn
7344
7345 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7346 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7347 @end deffn
7348
7349 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7350 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7351 @end deffn
7352
7353 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7354 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7355 @end deffn
7356
7357 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7358 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7359 @end deffn
7360
7361 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7362 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7363 @end deffn
7364
7365 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7366 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7367 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7368 and modifying how it is emptied.
7369 @end deffn
7370
7371 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7372 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7373 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7374 The image @var{type} may be one of
7375 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7376 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7377 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7381 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7382 @cindex vector_catch
7383 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7384 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7385
7386 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7387 @example
7388 0x01 Trap Reset
7389 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7390 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7391 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7392 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7393 0x20 reserved
7394 0x40 Trap IRQ
7395 0x80 Trap FIQ
7396 @end example
7397 @end deffn
7398
7399 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7400 @cindex vector_table
7401
7402 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7403 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7404 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7405 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7406 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7407
7408 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7409
7410 @end deffn
7411
7412 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7413 @cindex ARMv6
7414
7415 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7416 @cindex ARM11
7417
7418 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7419 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7420 which is enabled by default.
7421 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7422 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7423 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7424 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7425 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7426 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7427 @end deffn
7428
7429 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7430 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7431 which is enabled by default.
7432 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7433 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7434 @end deffn
7435
7436 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7437 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7438 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7439 they are disabled by default.
7440 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7444 @cindex vector_catch
7445 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7446 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7447 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7448
7449 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7450 for certain hardware events.
7451 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7452 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7453 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7454 @end deffn
7455
7456 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7457 @cindex ARMv7
7458
7459 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7460 @cindex Debug Access Port
7461 @cindex DAP
7462 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7463 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7464 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7465
7466 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7467 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7468 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7469 @end deffn
7470
7471 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7472 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7473 @end deffn
7474
7475 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7476 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7477 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7481 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7482 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7486 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7487 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7488 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7489 @end deffn
7490
7491 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7492 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7493 Defaulting to 0.
7494 @end deffn
7495
7496 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7497 @cindex tracing
7498 @cindex SWO
7499 @cindex SWV
7500 @cindex TPIU
7501 @cindex ITM
7502 @cindex ETM
7503
7504 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal @var{filename}}) @
7505 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7506 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7507
7508 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7509 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7510 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7511 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7512
7513 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7514 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7515 debugger adapter features.
7516
7517 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7518 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7519
7520 Command options:
7521 @itemize @minus
7522 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7523 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7524 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7525 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7526 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7527 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7528 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7529 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7530 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7531 coding;
7532 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7533 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7534 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7535 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7536 data is to be output via SWO;
7537 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7538 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7539 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7540 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7541 rate automatically.
7542 @end itemize
7543
7544 Example usage:
7545 @enumerate
7546 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7547 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7548 enough to:
7549 @example
7550 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7551 ...
7552 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7553 ...
7554 @end example
7555 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7556 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7557 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7558 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7559 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7560 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7561 @example
7562 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7563 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7564 @end example
7565 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7566 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7567 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7568 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7569 @example
7570 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7571 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7572 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7573 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7574 @end example
7575 @end enumerate
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7579 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7580 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7584 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7585 @end deffn
7586
7587 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7588 @cindex Cortex-M
7589
7590 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7591 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7592
7593 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7594 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7595 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7596 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7597 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7598 the step command leaves with the core running.
7599
7600 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7601 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7602 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7603
7604 Default is @option{auto}.
7605 @end deffn
7606
7607 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7608 @cindex vector_catch
7609 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7610 for certain hardware events.
7611
7612 Parameters request interception of
7613 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7614 @option{none} of them,
7615 or one or more of the following:
7616 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7617 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7618 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7619 @option{irq_err},
7620 @option{state_err},
7621 @option{chk_err}, or
7622 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7623 @option{reset}.
7624 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7625 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7626 are mapped to HardFault.
7627 UsageFault checks for
7628 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7629 must also be explicitly enabled.
7630
7631 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7632 @end deffn
7633
7634 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7635 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7636 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7637 @itemize @minus
7638 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7639 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7640 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7641 @end itemize
7642 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7643 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7644 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7645 the peripherals.
7646 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7647 @end deffn
7648
7649 @section Intel Architecture
7650
7651 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7652 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7653 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7654 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7655 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7656 @itemize
7657 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7658 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7659 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7660 @end itemize
7661
7662 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7663 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7664 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7665
7666 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7667 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7668 @end deffn
7669
7670 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7671 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7672 @end deffn
7673
7674 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7675 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7676 @end deffn
7677
7678 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7679 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7680 @end deffn
7681
7682 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7683 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7684 @end deffn
7685
7686 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7687 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7688 @end deffn
7689
7690 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7691
7692 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7693 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7694
7695 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7696 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7697 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7698 @end deffn
7699 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7700 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7701
7702 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7703
7704 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7705 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7706 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7707 @end deffn
7708
7709 @subsection Registers commands
7710 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7711 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7712 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7713
7714 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7715
7716 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7717 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7718 and "timer" groups.
7719
7720 @emph{example:}
7721 @example
7722 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7723 @end example
7724
7725
7726 @end deffn
7727 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7728 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7729
7730 @emph{group} can be "system",
7731 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7732 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7733 @end deffn
7734
7735 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7736 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7737 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7738 @cindex tracing
7739 @cindex libdcc
7740 @cindex DCC
7741 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7742 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7743 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7744 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7745
7746 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7747 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7748 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7749 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7750 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7751 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7752
7753 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7754 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7755 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7756 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7757 The target being debugged may
7758 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7759 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7760 each supported by a command:
7761
7762 @itemize
7763 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7764 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7765 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7766 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7767
7768 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7769 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7770 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7771
7772 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7773 and then displayed at any time.
7774 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7775
7776 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7777 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7778 @end itemize
7779
7780 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7781 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7782 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7783 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7784 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7785 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7786 does the same thing.
7787
7788 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7789 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7790 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7791 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7792 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7793
7794 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7795 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7796 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7797 @end deffn
7798
7799 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7800 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7801 in the order they triggered.
7802 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7803 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7804 history records.
7805 @end deffn
7806
7807 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7808 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7809 they have been triggered.
7810 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7811 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7812 and associates it with that identifier.
7813
7814 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7815 are not related except by this command.
7816 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7817 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7818 @end deffn
7819
7820
7821 @node JTAG Commands
7822 @chapter JTAG Commands
7823 @cindex JTAG Commands
7824 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7825 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7826 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7827 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7828 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7829
7830 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7831 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7832
7833 @itemize @bullet
7834 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7835 devices such as a CPUs.
7836 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7837 standard state machine (in parallel)
7838 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7839 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7840 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7841 while the reading previous ones.
7842 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7843 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7844 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7845 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7846 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7847 registers.
7848 @end itemize
7849
7850 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7851
7852 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7853 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7854 the order of TAP state transitions.
7855 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7856 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7857 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7858 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7859 these commands are not available.
7860
7861 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7862 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7863 that specify the entire register.
7864 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
7865 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
7866 The return value holds the original value of each
7867 of those fields.
7868
7869 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
7870 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
7871 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
7872 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
7873 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
7874
7875 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
7876 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
7877
7878 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7879 in that state.
7880 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
7881 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7882 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7883
7884 @quotation Warning
7885 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
7886 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
7887 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
7888 data registers, which may have different lengths.
7889 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
7890 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
7891 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
7892 (by connecting a different scan chain).
7893 @end quotation
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn Command {flush_count}
7897 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
7898 This may be used for performance tuning.
7899
7900 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
7901 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
7902 not change with the amount of data which is written.
7903 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
7904 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
7905 instead of batching them into larger operations.
7906 @end deffn
7907
7908 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7909 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
7910 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
7911 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
7912 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
7913 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
7914
7915 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
7916 in that state.
7917 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
7918 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
7919 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
7920
7921 @quotation Note
7922 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
7923 register values, unlike data register values.
7924 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
7925 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
7926 @end quotation
7927 @end deffn
7928
7929 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
7930 Set values of reset signals.
7931 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
7932 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
7933 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
7934 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7935 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
7936 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7937 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7938
7939 Note that TRST is specially handled.
7940 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7941 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7942 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7943 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7944 instead of the TRST signal.
7945 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7946 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7947 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7948 with handlers for that event.
7949 @end deffn
7950
7951 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
7952 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
7953 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
7954 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
7955 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
7956 Then, in a series of single state transitions
7957 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
7958 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
7959 The final state must also be stable.
7960 @end deffn
7961
7962 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
7963 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
7964 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
7965 Instructions often need some time
7966 to execute before they take effect.
7967 @end deffn
7968
7969 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
7970 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
7971
7972 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7973 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
7974 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
7975 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
7976 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
7977 @end deffn
7978
7979 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7980 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
7981 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
7982 must also be enabled.
7983 Default is enabled.
7984 @end deffn
7985
7986 @section TAP state names
7987 @cindex TAP state names
7988
7989 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
7990 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
7991 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
7992 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
7993
7994 @itemize @bullet
7995 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
7996 acts as if TRST were pulsed
7997 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
7998 @item @b{DRSELECT}
7999 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8000 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8001 through the data register
8002 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8003 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8004 for update or more shifting
8005 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8006 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8007 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8008 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8009 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8010 through the instruction register
8011 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8012 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8013 for update or more shifting
8014 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8015 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8016 @end itemize
8017
8018 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8019 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8020 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8021 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8022
8023 @itemize @bullet
8024 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8025 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8026 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8027 may not be as expected.
8028 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8029 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8030 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8031 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8032 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8033 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8034 @end itemize
8035
8036 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8037 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8038
8039 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8040 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8041 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8042 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8043
8044 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8045 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8046 @cindex SVF
8047
8048 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8049 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8050 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8051 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8052
8053 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8054 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8055 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8056 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8057 each command is logged before it is executed.
8058 @end deffn
8059
8060 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8061 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8062 @cindex XSVF
8063
8064 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8065 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8066 Xilinx devices.
8067 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8068 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8069
8070 @quotation Important
8071 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8072 @end quotation
8073
8074 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8075 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8076 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8077 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8078 that TAP.
8079 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8080 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8081 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8082 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8083 @end deffn
8084
8085 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8086 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8087 after building the software.
8088 You may find them useful:
8089
8090 @itemize
8091 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8092 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8093 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8094 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8095 @end itemize
8096
8097 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8098 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8099 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8100 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8101 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8102 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8103 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8104
8105
8106 @node Utility Commands
8107 @chapter Utility Commands
8108 @cindex Utility Commands
8109
8110 @section RAM testing
8111 @cindex RAM testing
8112
8113 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8114 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8115 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8116 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8117 hardware problems.
8118
8119 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8120 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8121 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8122 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8123
8124 Load the memory testing functions with
8125
8126 @example
8127 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8128 @end example
8129
8130 to get access to the following facilities:
8131
8132 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8133 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8134 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8135 @end deffn
8136
8137 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8138 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8139 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8140 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8141 @end deffn
8142
8143 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8144 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8145 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8146 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8147 @end deffn
8148
8149 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8150 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8151 @end deffn
8152
8153 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8154 @cindex Firmware recovery
8155
8156 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8157 devices recovery with JTAG.
8158
8159 For quickstart instructions run:
8160 @example
8161 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8162 @end example
8163
8164 @node TFTP
8165 @chapter TFTP
8166 @cindex TFTP
8167 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8168 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8169
8170 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8171 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8172 server (tftpd). For example,
8173
8174 @example
8175 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8176 @end example
8177
8178 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8179 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8180
8181 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8182 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8183 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8184 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8185
8186 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8187 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8188 @cindex GDB
8189 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8190 to debug remote targets.
8191 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8192
8193 @itemize
8194 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8195 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8196 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8197 as shown in this chapter.
8198 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8199 that also will probably need to be configured.
8200 @end itemize
8201
8202 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8203 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8204 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8205 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8206 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8207 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8208
8209 @section Connecting to GDB
8210 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8211 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8212 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8213 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8214 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8215
8216 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8217
8218 @enumerate
8219 @item
8220 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8221 @example
8222 target remote localhost:3333
8223 @end example
8224 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8225
8226 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8227 @example
8228 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8229 @end example
8230 @item
8231 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8232 @example
8233 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8234 @end example
8235 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8236 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8237 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8238 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8239 @end enumerate
8240
8241 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8242 GDB command line.
8243
8244 @section Sample GDB session startup
8245
8246 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8247 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8248 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8249 small ARM program.
8250 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8251 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8252
8253 @example
8254 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8255 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8256 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8257 ...
8258 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8259 ...
8260 (gdb) load
8261 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8262 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8263 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8264 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8265 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8266 (gdb) continue
8267 Continuing.
8268 ...
8269 @end example
8270
8271 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8272 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8273 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8274 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8275
8276 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8277
8278 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8279 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8280 packet size and the device's memory map.
8281 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8282 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8283 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8284
8285 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8286 You may need to set those up by hand.
8287 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8288 something like:
8289
8290 @example
8291 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8292 @end example
8293
8294 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8295
8296 @example
8297 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8298 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8299 @end example
8300
8301 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8302 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8303 do not have such restrictions.
8304
8305 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8306 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8307 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8308
8309 @example
8310 define hook-step
8311 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8312 end
8313 define hookpost-step
8314 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8315 end
8316 @end example
8317
8318 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8319 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8320 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8321 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8322
8323 @section Programming using GDB
8324 @cindex Programming using GDB
8325 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8326
8327 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8328 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8329 @example
8330 gdb_memory_map disable
8331 @end example
8332 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8333 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8334 working area.
8335
8336 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8337 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8338 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8339 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8340
8341 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8342 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8343
8344 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8345 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8346 @example
8347 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8348 @end example
8349
8350 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8351 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8352
8353 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8354 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8355 will be used.
8356
8357 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8358 script can be executed:
8359 @example
8360 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8361 @end example
8362
8363 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8364 can be used.
8365 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8366 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8367 @cindex SMP
8368 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8369 @itemize @bullet
8370 @item j - smp status request
8371 @item J - smp set request
8372 @end itemize
8373
8374 OpenOCD implements :
8375 @itemize @bullet
8376 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8377 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8378 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8379 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8380 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8381 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8382 @end itemize
8383
8384 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8385 @itemize @bullet
8386 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8387 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8388 @example
8389 set $_core 1
8390 #Jc01 packet is sent
8391 print $_core
8392 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8393 @end example
8394
8395 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8396 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8397
8398 @example
8399 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8400 define toggle0
8401 maint packet Jc0
8402 continue
8403 main packet Jc-1
8404 end
8405 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8406 define toggle1
8407 maint packet Jc1
8408 continue
8409 main packet Jc-1
8410 end
8411 @end example
8412 @end itemize
8413
8414 @section RTOS Support
8415 @cindex RTOS Support
8416 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8417
8418 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8419 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8420
8421 @* An example setup is below:
8422
8423 @example
8424 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8425 @end example
8426
8427 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8428
8429 Currently supported rtos's include:
8430 @itemize @bullet
8431 @item @option{eCos}
8432 @item @option{ThreadX}
8433 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8434 @item @option{linux}
8435 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8436 @item @option{embKernel}
8437 @item @option{mqx}
8438 @end itemize
8439
8440 @quotation Note
8441 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8442 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8443 @end quotation
8444
8445 @table @code
8446 @item eCos symbols
8447 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8448 @item ThreadX symbols
8449 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8450 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8451 @raggedright
8452 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8453 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8454 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8455 @end raggedright
8456 @item linux symbols
8457 init_task.
8458 @item ChibiOS symbols
8459 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8460 @item embKernel symbols
8461 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8462 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8463 @item mqx symbols
8464 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8465 @end table
8466
8467 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8468 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8469
8470 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8471 along with the project:
8472
8473 @table @code
8474 @item FreeRTOS
8475 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8476 @end table
8477
8478 @node Tcl Scripting API
8479 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8480 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8481 @cindex Tcl scripts
8482 @section API rules
8483
8484 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8485 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8486 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8487
8488 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8489 pair list and lists.
8490
8491 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8492 list.
8493
8494 @example
8495 > set foo(me) Duane
8496 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8497 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8498 > set foo(duck) Donald
8499 @end example
8500
8501 If one does this:
8502
8503 @example
8504 > set foo
8505 @end example
8506
8507 The result is:
8508
8509 @example
8510 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8511 @end example
8512
8513 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8514
8515 @verbatim
8516 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8517 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8518 }
8519 @end verbatim
8520
8521 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8522 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8523
8524 @section Internal low-level Commands
8525
8526 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8527 invoke directly.
8528
8529 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8530 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8531 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8532
8533 @itemize @bullet
8534 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8535
8536 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8537 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8538
8539 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8540 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8541
8542 Return information about the flash banks
8543
8544 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8545
8546 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8547 its execution. Example:
8548
8549 @example
8550 > capture "reset init"
8551 @end example
8552
8553 @end itemize
8554
8555 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8556 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8557 called "flash_banks".
8558
8559 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8560
8561 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8562 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8563 holds one of the following values:
8564
8565 @itemize @bullet
8566 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8567 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8568 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8569 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8570 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8571 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8572 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8573 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8574 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8575 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8576 @end itemize
8577
8578 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8579
8580 @quotation Note
8581 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8582 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8583 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8584 is jim, not real tcl).
8585 @end quotation
8586
8587 @section Tcl RPC server
8588 @cindex RPC
8589
8590 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8591 commands and receive the results.
8592
8593 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8594 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8595 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8596 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8597 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8598
8599 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8600 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8601 @command{capture} command.
8602
8603 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8604
8605 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8606 @cindex RPC Notifications
8607
8608 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8609 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8610
8611 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8612 in the following format.
8613
8614 @verbatim
8615 type target_event event [event-name]
8616 type target_state state [state-name]
8617 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8618 @end verbatim
8619
8620 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8621 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8622 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8623 Defaults to off.
8624
8625 @end deffn
8626
8627 @node FAQ
8628 @chapter FAQ
8629 @cindex faq
8630 @enumerate
8631 @anchor{faqrtck}
8632 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8633 @cindex RTCK
8634 @cindex adaptive clocking
8635 @*
8636
8637 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8638 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8639 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8640 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8641
8642 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8643 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8644 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8645 @enumerate
8646 @item
8647 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8648 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8649 @item
8650 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8651 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8652 @end enumerate
8653
8654 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8655 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8656 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8657 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8658 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8659 power).
8660
8661 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8662 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8663 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8664 ARM926 scenario).
8665 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8666 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8667 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8668
8669 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8670 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8671 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8672 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8673
8674 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8675
8676 In order to make use of this,
8677 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8678 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8679
8680 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8681 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8682 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8683 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8684 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8685
8686 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8687 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8688 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8689 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8690
8691 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8692 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8693 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8694 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8695 with a CPLD.
8696 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8697 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8698 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8699 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8700 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8701 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8702
8703 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8704
8705 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8706
8707 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8708 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8709 depending on the chips on your board.
8710 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8711 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8712 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8713
8714 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8715 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8716 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8717
8718 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8719 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8720 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8721 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8722
8723 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8724 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8725 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8726 this way.
8727
8728 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8729 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8730 clock rate.
8731 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8732 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8733 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8734
8735 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8736
8737 @example
8738 # Example: 1.234MHz
8739 adapter_khz 1234
8740 @end example
8741
8742
8743 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8744
8745 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8746 around Windows filenames.
8747
8748 @example
8749 > echo \a
8750
8751 > echo @{\a@}
8752 \a
8753 > echo "\a"
8754
8755 >
8756 @end example
8757
8758
8759 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8760
8761 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8762 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8763 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8764
8765 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8766 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8767 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8768
8769 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8770 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8771 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8772
8773 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8774
8775 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8776 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8777 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8778 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8779
8780 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8781 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8782 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8783
8784 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8785 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8786
8787 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8788 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8789 memory read caused data abort".
8790
8791 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8792 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8793 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8794 be done, feel free to add this here.
8795
8796 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8797 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8798 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8799 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8800 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8801 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8802 gracefully stops.
8803
8804 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8805 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8806 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8807
8808 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8809 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8810 bytes. Painful...
8811
8812
8813 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8814 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8815
8816 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8817 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8818 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8819 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8820 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8821 reset, everything else should work fine.
8822
8823 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8824 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8825 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8826 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8827
8828 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8829 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8830 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8831 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8832
8833 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8834
8835 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
8836 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
8837 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
8838 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8839
8840 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
8841 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
8842 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
8843 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
8844
8845 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
8846 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
8847 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
8848
8849 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
8850 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
8851
8852 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
8853 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
8854 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
8855 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
8856 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
8857 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
8858 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
8859 clock frequency?
8860
8861 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
8862 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
8863 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
8864 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
8865 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
8866
8867 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
8868
8869 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
8870 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
8871 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
8872 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
8873 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
8874 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
8875 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
8876
8877 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
8878
8879 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
8880 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
8881 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
8882 up DRAM and loading it with code.
8883
8884 @anchor{faqtaporder}
8885 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
8886 particular order?
8887
8888 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
8889 the same order used by the hardware.
8890
8891 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
8892 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
8893 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
8894 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
8895 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
8896 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
8897
8898 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
8899 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
8900 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
8901 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
8902
8903 @itemize @bullet
8904 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
8905 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
8906 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
8907 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
8908 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
8909 @end itemize
8910
8911 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
8912
8913 @itemize @bullet
8914 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
8915 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
8916 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
8917 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
8918 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
8919 @end itemize
8920
8921
8922 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
8923 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
8924 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
8925
8926 TODO.
8927
8928 @end enumerate
8929
8930 @node Tcl Crash Course
8931 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
8932 @cindex Tcl
8933
8934 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
8935 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
8936 how the Tcl scripts work.
8937
8938 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
8939 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
8940 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
8941 OpenOCD.
8942
8943 @section Tcl Rule #1
8944 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
8945 @enumerate
8946 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
8947 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8948 @end enumerate
8949
8950 The Tcl equal is this:
8951
8952 @enumerate
8953 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
8954 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8955 @end enumerate
8956
8957 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
8958 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
8959
8960 @section Tcl Rule #1b
8961 There is a second pair of rules.
8962 @enumerate
8963 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
8964 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
8965 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
8966 in Tcl.
8967 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
8968 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
8969 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
8970 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
8971 @end enumerate
8972
8973 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
8974 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
8975 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
8976 Everything is a string}
8977
8978 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
8979 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
8980 difference is subtle.
8981 @enumerate
8982 @item Parse Time
8983 @item Evaluation Time
8984 @end enumerate
8985
8986 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
8987 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
8988 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
8989
8990 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
8991 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
8992 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
8993 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
8994
8995 @itemize @bullet
8996 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
8997 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
8998 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
8999 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9000 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9001 @example
9002 # bash example
9003 X=`date`
9004 echo "The Date is: $X"
9005 # Tcl example
9006 set X [date]
9007 puts "The Date is: $X"
9008 @end example
9009 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9010 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9011 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9012 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9013 is a string}
9014 @example
9015 set x "Dinner"
9016 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9017 @end example
9018 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9019 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9020 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9021 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9022 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9023 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9024 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9025 @end itemize
9026
9027 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9028
9029 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9030
9031 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9032
9033 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9034 the normal way.
9035
9036 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9037 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9038 line is immedatly executed.
9039
9040 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9041 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9042
9043 @subsection Command Execution
9044
9045 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9046 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9047 control flow operators.
9048
9049 Commands are executed like this:
9050
9051 @enumerate
9052 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9053 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9054 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9055 @end enumerate
9056
9057 It sort of works like this:
9058 @example
9059 for(;;)@{
9060 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9061
9062 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9063
9064 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9065 @}
9066 @end example
9067
9068 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9069 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9070 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9071 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9072 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9073 ``LookupCommand()''
9074
9075 @subsection The FOR command
9076
9077 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9078 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9079 command just like any other command.
9080
9081 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9082 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9083 are:
9084
9085 @enumerate 0
9086 @item The ascii text 'for'
9087 @item The start text
9088 @item The test expression
9089 @item The next text
9090 @item The body text
9091 @end enumerate
9092
9093 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9094 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9095 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9096 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9097
9098 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9099 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9100
9101 @example
9102 int
9103 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9104 int *argc,
9105 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9106 @end example
9107
9108 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9109 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9110 still operates in the same basic way.
9111
9112 @subsection FOR command implementation
9113
9114 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9115 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9116
9117 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9118
9119 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9120
9121 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9122 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9123 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9124
9125 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9126 expression and returns a value.
9127
9128 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9129 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9130 @example
9131 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9132
9133 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9134
9135 int
9136 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9137 int argc,
9138 char **argv )
9139 @{
9140 if( argc != 5 )@{
9141 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9142 return ERROR;
9143 @}
9144
9145 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9146
9147 // Execute the start statement.
9148 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9149
9150 // Top of loop test
9151 for(;;)@{
9152 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9153 if( i == 0 )
9154 break;
9155
9156 // Execute the body
9157 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9158
9159 // Execute the LOOP part
9160 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9161 @}
9162
9163 // Return no error
9164 SetResult( interp, "" );
9165 return SUCCESS;
9166 @}
9167 @end example
9168
9169 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9170 in the same basic way.
9171
9172 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9173
9174 @subsection source and find commands
9175 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9176 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9177 @*Remember the parsing rules
9178 @enumerate
9179 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9180 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9181 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9182 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9183 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9184 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9185 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9186 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9187 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9188 @end enumerate
9189 @subsection format command
9190 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9191 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9192 @b{sprintf()}.
9193 @b{Example}
9194 @example
9195 set x 6
9196 set y 7
9197 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9198 @end example
9199 @enumerate
9200 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9201 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9202 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9203 @* Refer to Rule #1
9204 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9205 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9206 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9207 @end enumerate
9208 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9209 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9210 @example
9211 #1 Good
9212 proc someproc @{@} @{
9213 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9214 @}
9215 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9216 #2 Good - no variables
9217 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9218 #3 Good Curly Braces
9219 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9220 puts "Time: [date]"
9221 @}
9222 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9223 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9224 @end example
9225 @enumerate
9226 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9227 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9228 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9229 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9230 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9231 command.
9232 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9233 @*There are 4 examples:
9234 @enumerate
9235 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9236 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9237 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9238 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9239 @end enumerate
9240
9241 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9242 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9243 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9244
9245 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9246 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9247 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9248 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9249 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9250 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9251 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9252 @end enumerate
9253 @subsection Global Variables
9254 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9255 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9256 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9257 @example
9258 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9259 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9260 global x #Global variable X
9261 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9262 @}
9263 @end example
9264 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9265 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9266 @example
9267 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9268 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9269 # Create var name
9270 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9271 # Make it a global
9272 global $vn
9273 # Set it.
9274 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9275 @}
9276 @end example
9277 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9278 @example
9279 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9280 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9281 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9282 @}
9283 @end example
9284
9285 @include fdl.texi
9286
9287 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9288 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9289 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9290 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9291 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9292 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9293
9294 @printindex cp
9295
9296 @node Command and Driver Index
9297 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9298 @printindex fn
9299
9300 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)